blob: 793dc42759b05c88d4251cfd564c0a007d7f7d86 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000041
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +000059 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
60 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
61 // emit them now.
62 llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >::iterator
63 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
64 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
65 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
66 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
67 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
68
69 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
70 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't remove this
71 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
72 // diagnostics again.
73 Suppressed.clear();
74 }
75 }
76
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000077 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerbfac7dc2010-10-09 15:49:00 +000078 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
79 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000080
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000081 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc74073c2010-10-06 23:12:32 +000082 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
83 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
84 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
85 else
86 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerbfac7dc2010-10-09 15:49:00 +000087 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000088 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
89 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000090
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000091 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000092 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000093 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
94 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
95 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
96 return true;
97 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000098 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000099
Anders Carlsson73067a02010-10-22 23:37:08 +0000100 // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
101 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
102 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
103
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000104 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +0000105}
106
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000107/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000108/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000109/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
110///
111void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000112 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +0000113 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000114 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000115 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000116
117 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
118 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000119 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
120 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000121
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000122 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
123 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000124 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000125 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
126 int isMethod = 0;
127 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
128 // skip over named parameters.
129 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
130 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
131 if (nullPos)
132 --nullPos;
133 else
134 ++i;
135 }
136 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
137 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000138 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000139 // skip over named parameters.
140 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
141 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
142 if (nullPos)
143 --nullPos;
144 else
145 ++i;
146 }
147 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000148 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000149 // block or function pointer call.
150 QualType Ty = V->getType();
151 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000152 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000153 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
154 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000155 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
156 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
157 unsigned k;
158 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
159 if (nullPos)
160 --nullPos;
161 else
162 ++i;
163 }
164 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
165 }
166 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
167 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000168 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000169 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000170 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000171 return;
172
173 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000174 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000175 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000176 return;
177 }
178 int sentinel = i;
179 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
180 --sentinelPos;
181 ++i;
182 }
183 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
184 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000185 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000186 return;
187 }
188 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
189 ++i;
190 ++sentinel;
191 }
192 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000193 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
194 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
195 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000196 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000197 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
198 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
199 return;
200
201 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
202 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
203
204 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
205 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000206}
207
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000208SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
209 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
210 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
211}
212
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
214// Standard Promotions and Conversions
215//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
216
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000217/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
218void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
219 QualType Ty = E->getType();
220 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
221
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000222 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000223 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000224 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000225 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
226 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
227 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
228 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
229 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
230 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
231 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000232 //
233 // C++ 4.2p1:
234 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
235 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
236 //
237 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
238 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000239 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000240 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000241 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000242}
243
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000244void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
245 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000246
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000247 QualType Ty = E->getType();
248 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
249 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
250 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
251 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
252 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
253 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
254 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
255 // rvalue is T
256 //
257 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000258 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
259 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000260 // type of the lvalue.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000262 }
263}
264
265
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000266/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000267/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000268/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
269/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
270/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
271Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
272 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
273 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000274
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000275 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
276 //
277 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
278 // unsigned int may be used:
279 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
280 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
281 // and unsigned int.
282 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
283 //
284 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
285 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
286 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
287 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000288 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
289 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000290 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000291 return Expr;
292 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000293 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000294 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000295 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000296 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000297 }
298
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000299 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000300 return Expr;
301}
302
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000303/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000304/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000305/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
306void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
307 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
308 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000309
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000310 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000311 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
312 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000313 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000314
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000315 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
316}
317
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000318/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
319/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
320/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
321/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000322bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
323 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000324 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000325
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000326 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
327 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
328 // etc.
329 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
330 return false;
331
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000332 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000333 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
334 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
335 << Expr->getType() << CT))
336 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000337
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000338 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000339 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000340 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
341 << Expr->getType() << CT))
342 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000343
344 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000345}
346
347
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000348/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
349/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000350/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000351/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
352/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
353/// GCC.
354QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
355 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000356 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000357 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000358
359 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000361 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000362 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000363 QualType lhs =
364 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000365 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000366 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000367
368 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
369 if (lhs == rhs)
370 return lhs;
371
372 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
373 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
374 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
375 return lhs;
376
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000377 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000378 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000379 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
380 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000381 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000382 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
383 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
384
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000385 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000386 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000387 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
388 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000389 return destType;
390}
391
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000392//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
393// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
394//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
395
396
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000397/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000398/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
399/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
400/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
401/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000402///
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000403ExprResult
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000404Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000405 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
406
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000407 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000408 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000409 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000410
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000411 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000412 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
413 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000414
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000415 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000416 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000417 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000418
419 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000420 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000421 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000422
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000423 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
424 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
425 // strings.
426 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000427 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000428 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000429
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000430 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000431 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
432 Literal.GetStringLength(),
433 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
434 &StringTokLocs[0],
435 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000436}
437
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000438/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
439/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
440/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
441/// for values inside the block or for globals).
442///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000443/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000444/// up-to-date.
445///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000446static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000447 ValueDecl *VD) {
448 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
449 // we wanted to.
450 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000453 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
454 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
455 return false;
456
457 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
458 // snapshot it.
459 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
460 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000461 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
462 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000463
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000464 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
465 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
466
467 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
468 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
469 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
470 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000471 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
472 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000473
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000474 if (!NextBlock)
475 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000476
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000477 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
478 // having a reference outside it.
479 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
480 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000481
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000482 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
483 // a snapshot as well.
484 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
485 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000486
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000487 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000488}
489
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000490
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000491ExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000492Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000493 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000494 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
495 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
496}
497
498/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000499ExprResult
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000500Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
501 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
502 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000503 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000504 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000505 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000506 << D->getDeclName();
507 return ExprError();
508 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000509
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000510 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000511 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
512 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
513 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000514 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000515 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000516 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
517 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000518 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
519 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000520 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000521 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000522 << D->getIdentifier();
523 return ExprError();
524 }
525 }
526 }
527 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000528
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000529 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000530
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000531 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
532 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
533 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000534 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000535}
536
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000537/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
538/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
539/// actual member.
540///
541/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
542/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
543/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
544/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
545/// we found.
546///
547/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
548/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
549/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
550VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
551 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000552 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
553 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
554 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
555
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000556 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000557 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
558 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
559 do {
560 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000561 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000562 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000563 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000564 else {
565 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
566 break;
567 }
568 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000569 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000570 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000571
572 return BaseObject;
573}
574
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000575ExprResult
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000576Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
577 FieldDecl *Field,
578 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
579 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
580 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000581 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000582 AnonFields);
583
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
585 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
586 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
587 // found via name lookup.
588 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000589 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 if (BaseObject) {
591 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
592 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000593 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000594 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Devang Patele25b5f82010-10-12 23:23:25 +0000595 Loc);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000596 BaseQuals
597 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000598 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
599 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
600 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
601 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
602 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000603 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000604 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
605 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
606 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 BaseQuals
608 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000609 } else {
610 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
611 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
612 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000613 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
614 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000615 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000616 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000617 = Context.getTagDeclType(
618 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
619 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000620 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000621 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
622 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
623 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000624 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000625 MD->getThisType(Context),
626 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000627 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
628 }
629 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000630 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
631 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000632 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000633 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000634 }
635
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000636 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000637 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
638 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000639 }
640
641 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
642 // anonymous struct/union.
643 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000644 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000645 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
646 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
647 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
648 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000649 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
650 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
651
652 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
653 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
654 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
655 ResultQuals.removeConst();
656
657 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
658 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
659
660 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
661 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
662
663 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
664 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
665 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
666
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000667 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000668 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000669 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000670 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
671 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000672 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000673 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000674 }
675
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000676 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000677}
678
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000679/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000680/// possibly a list of template arguments.
681///
682/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
683/// DecomposeTemplateName.
684///
685/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
686/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
687/// some way.
688static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
689 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
690 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000691 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000692 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
693 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
694 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
695 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
696
697 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
698 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
699 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
700 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
701 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
702
John McCall3e56fd42010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000703 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000704 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
705 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000706 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
707 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000708 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000709 TemplateArgs = 0;
710 }
711}
712
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000713/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
714/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
715/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000716static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000717 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
718 return false;
719
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000720 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
721 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
722 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
723 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
724 if (!BaseRT) return false;
725
726 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000727 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000728 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
729 return false;
730 }
731
732 return true;
733}
734
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000735/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
736/// the prospective base classes.
737static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
738 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
739 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000740 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000741 return false;
742
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000743 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000744 if (!RD) return false;
745 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
746
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000747 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
748 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
749 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
750 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
751 if (!BaseRT) return false;
752
753 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000754 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
755 return false;
756 }
757
758 return true;
759}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000760
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000761enum IMAKind {
762 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
763 IMA_Static,
764
765 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
766 IMA_Mixed,
767
768 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
769 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
770 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
771
772 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
773 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
774 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
775
776 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
777 IMA_Instance,
778
779 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
780 IMA_Unresolved,
781
782 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
783 /// context is not an instance method.
784 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
785
786 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
787 /// non-class context.
788 IMA_AnonymousMember,
789
790 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
791 /// context is not an instance method.
792 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
793
794 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
795 /// class.
796 IMA_Error_Unrelated
797};
798
799/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
800/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
801/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
802/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
803/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
804/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
805static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
806 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000807 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000808
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000809 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000810 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000811 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
812 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000813
814 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
815 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
816
817 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
818 bool hasNonInstance = false;
819 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
820 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000821 NamedDecl *D = *I;
822 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000823 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
824
825 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
826 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
827 // that's a special case.
828 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
829 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
830 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
831 }
832 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
833 }
834 else
835 hasNonInstance = true;
836 }
837
838 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
839 // member reference.
840 if (Classes.empty())
841 return IMA_Static;
842
843 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
844 // an implicit member reference.
845 if (isStaticContext)
846 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
847
848 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
849 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
850 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
851 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000852 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000853 Classes))
854 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
855
856 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
857}
858
859/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
860static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
861 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
862 const LookupResult &R) {
863 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
864 SourceRange Range(Loc);
865 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
866
867 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
868 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
869 if (MD->isStatic()) {
870 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
871 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
872 << Range << R.getLookupName();
873 return;
874 }
875 }
876
877 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
878 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
879 return;
880 }
881
882 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000883}
884
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000885/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
886///
887/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000888bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
889 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000890 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
891
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000892 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000893 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000894 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
895 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000896 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000897 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000898 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
899 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000900
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000901 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
902 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
903 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
904 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000905 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000906 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000907 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
908 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
909
910 if (!R.empty()) {
911 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
912 R.suppressDiagnostics();
913
914 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
915 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
916 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
917 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
918
919 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
920 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
921 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000922 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000923 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
924 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000925 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000926 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000927 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000928 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
929 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
930 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
931 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
932 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
933 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
934 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
935 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
936 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
937 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
938 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
939 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
940 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
941 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000942 } else {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000943 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
944 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
945 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000946 }
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000947 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000948 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000949 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000950
951 // Do we really want to note all of these?
952 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
953 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
954
955 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
956 return false;
957 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000958
959 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000960 }
961 }
962
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000963 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000964 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000965 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000966 if (!R.empty()) {
967 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
968 if (SS.isEmpty())
969 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
970 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
971 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
972 else
973 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
974 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
975 << SS.getRange()
976 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
977 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
978 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
979 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
980 << ND->getDeclName();
981
982 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
983 return false;
984 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000985
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000986 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
987 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
988 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
989 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
990 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
991 // to recover well anyway.
992 if (SS.isEmpty())
993 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
994 else
995 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
996 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
997 << SS.getRange();
998
999 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1000 return true;
1001 }
1002 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001003 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001004 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001005 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001006 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001007 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001008 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001009 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1010 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001011 return true;
1012 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001013 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001014 }
1015
1016 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1017 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1018 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1019 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1020 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1021 << SS.getRange();
1022 return true;
1023 }
1024
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001025 // Give up, we can't recover.
1026 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1027 return true;
1028}
1029
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001030static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001031 IdentifierInfo *II,
1032 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001033 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1034 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1035 if (!IDecl)
1036 return 0;
1037 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1038 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1039 return 0;
1040 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1041 if (!property)
1042 return 0;
1043 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1044 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1045 return 0;
1046 return property;
1047}
1048
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001049static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001050 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001051 IdentifierInfo *II,
1052 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1053 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001054 bool LookForIvars;
1055 if (Lookup.empty())
1056 LookForIvars = true;
1057 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1058 LookForIvars = false;
1059 else
1060 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1061 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1062 if (!LookForIvars)
1063 return 0;
1064
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001065 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1066 if (!IDecl)
1067 return 0;
1068 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001069 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1070 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001071 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1072 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1073 if (!property)
1074 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianbfcbc852010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001075 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II)) {
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001076 DynamicImplSeen =
1077 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
Fariborz Jahanianbfcbc852010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001078 // property implementation has a designated ivar. No need to assume a new
1079 // one.
1080 if (!DynamicImplSeen && PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1081 return 0;
1082 }
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001083 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001084 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1085 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001086 NameLoc,
1087 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1088 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1089 (Expr *)0, true);
1090 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1091 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1092 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1093 return Ivar;
1094 }
1095 return 0;
1096}
1097
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001098ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001099 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1100 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1101 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1102 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001103 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1104 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1105
1106 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001107 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001108
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001109 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001110
1111 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001112 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001113 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001114 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001115
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001116 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001117 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001118 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001119
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001120 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1121 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001122 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1123 // (note: handled after lookup)
1124 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1125 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1126 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001127 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1128 // names a dependent type.
1129 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1130 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001131 bool DependentID = false;
1132 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1133 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1134 DependentID = true;
1135 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1136 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1137 if (DC) {
1138 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1139 return ExprError();
1140 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1141 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1142 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1143 } else {
1144 DependentID = true;
1145 }
1146 }
1147
1148 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001149 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001150 TemplateArgs);
1151 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001152 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001153 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001154 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001155 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001156 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1157 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1158 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1159 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1160 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001161 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1162 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1163 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001164 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001165 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001166 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001167
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001168 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1169 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001170 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001171 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001172 if (E.isInvalid())
1173 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001174
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001175 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1176 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001177 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1178 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001179 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001180 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1181 isAddressOfOperand);
1182 }
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001183 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1184 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001185 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001186 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001187
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001188 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1189 return ExprError();
1190
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001191 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1192 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001193 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001194
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001195 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001196 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001197 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1198 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1199 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1200 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1201 }
1202
1203 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1204 // call, diagnose the problem.
1205 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001206 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001207 return ExprError();
1208
1209 assert(!R.empty() &&
1210 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001211
1212 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1213 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001214 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001215 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1216 R.clear();
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001217 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001218 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1219 return move(E);
1220 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001221 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001222 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001223
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001224 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1225 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1226
1227 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001228 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001229 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1230 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001231 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1232 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1233 if (Property) {
1234 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1235 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001236 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001237 }
1238 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001239 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001240 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1241 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1242 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1243 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1244 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1245 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001246 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001247 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001248
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001249 QualType T = Func->getType();
1250 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001251 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001252 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1253 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001254 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001255 }
1256 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001257
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001258 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001259 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1260 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1261 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1262 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1263 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1264 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1265 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1266 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001267 //
1268 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1269 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1270 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1271 // non-static member function:
1272 //
1273 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1274 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1275 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1276 // member function call.
1277 //
1278 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1279 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1280 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1281 // instance method.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001282 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001283 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1284 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1285 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1286 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1287 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1288 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1289 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregor1262b062010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001290 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1291 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001292 else
1293 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1294
1295 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001296 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001297 }
1298
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001299 if (TemplateArgs)
1300 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001301
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001302 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1303}
1304
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001305/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001306ExprResult
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001307Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1308 LookupResult &R,
1309 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1310 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1311 case IMA_Instance:
1312 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1313
1314 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1315 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1316 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1317 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1318
1319 case IMA_Mixed:
1320 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1321 case IMA_Unresolved:
1322 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1323
1324 case IMA_Static:
1325 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1326 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1327 if (TemplateArgs)
1328 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1329 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1330
1331 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1332 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1333 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1334 return ExprError();
1335 }
1336
1337 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1338 return ExprError();
1339}
1340
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001341/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1342/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1343/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1344/// this path.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001345ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001346Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001347 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001348 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001349 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001350 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001351
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001352 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001353 return ExprError();
1354
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001355 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001356 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1357
1358 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1359 return ExprError();
1360
1361 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001362 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1363 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001364 return ExprError();
1365 }
1366
1367 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1368}
1369
1370/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1371/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1372/// additional lookup.
1373///
1374/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1375/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1376///
1377/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001378ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001379Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001380 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001381 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001382 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001383
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001384 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1385 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1386 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1387 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1388 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1389
1390 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1391 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1392 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001393 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001394
1395 bool LookForIvars;
1396 if (Lookup.empty())
1397 LookForIvars = true;
1398 else if (IsClassMethod)
1399 LookForIvars = false;
1400 else
1401 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1402 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001403 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001404 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001405 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001406 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1407 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1408 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1409 if (IsClassMethod)
1410 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1411 << IV->getDeclName());
1412
1413 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1414 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1415 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1416 return ExprError();
1417
1418 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1419 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1420 return ExprError();
1421
1422 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1423 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1424 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1425 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1426
1427 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1428 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1429 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1430 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001431 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001432 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001433 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregora1ed39b2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001434 SelfName, false, false);
1435 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1436 return ExprError();
1437
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001438 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1439 return Owned(new (Context)
1440 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1441 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1442 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001443 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001444 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001445 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001446 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1447 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1448 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1449 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1450 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1451 }
1452 }
1453
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001454 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1455 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1456 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1457 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1458 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1459 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1460 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1461 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1462 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1463 }
1464 }
1465 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001466 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1467 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001468}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001469
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001470/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1471///
1472/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1473///
1474/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1475/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1476/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1477/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1478///
1479/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1480/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1481/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1482/// the class declaring the member.
1483///
1484/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1485/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1486/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001487bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001488Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1489 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001490 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001491 NamedDecl *Member) {
1492 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1493 if (!RD)
1494 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001495
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001496 QualType DestRecordType;
1497 QualType DestType;
1498 QualType FromRecordType;
1499 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1500 bool PointerConversions = false;
1501 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1502 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001503
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001504 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1505 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1506 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1507 PointerConversions = true;
1508 } else {
1509 DestType = DestRecordType;
1510 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001511 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001512 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1513 if (Method->isStatic())
1514 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001515
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001516 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1517 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001518
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001519 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1520 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1521 PointerConversions = true;
1522 } else {
1523 FromRecordType = FromType;
1524 DestType = DestRecordType;
1525 }
1526 } else {
1527 // No conversion necessary.
1528 return false;
1529 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001530
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001531 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1532 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001533
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001534 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1535 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1536 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001537
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001538 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1539 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1540
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001541 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001542
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001543 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001544 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001545 // class name.
1546 //
1547 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1548 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1549 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1550 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1551 //
1552 // class Base { public: int x; };
1553 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1554 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1555 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1556 //
1557 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1558 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1559 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1560 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001561 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001562 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1563 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1564 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1565
1566 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1567
1568 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1569 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1570 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1571 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001572 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001573 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001574 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001575 return true;
1576
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001577 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001578 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001579 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1580 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001581
1582 FromType = QType;
1583 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1584
1585 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1586 // we're done.
1587 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1588 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001589 }
1590 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001591
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001592 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001593
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001594 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1595 // down to the using declaration's type.
1596 //
1597 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1598 // class ever has member declarations.
1599 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1600 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1601 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1602 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1603
1604 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1605 // conversion is non-trivial.
1606 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1607 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001608 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001609 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001610 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001611 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001612
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001613 QualType UType = URecordType;
1614 if (PointerConversions)
1615 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001616 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001617 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001618 FromType = UType;
1619 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1620 }
1621
1622 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1623 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1624 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001625 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001626
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001627 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001628 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1629 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001630 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001631 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001632
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001633 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001634 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001635 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001636}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001637
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001638/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001639static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001640 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001641 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001642 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1643 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001644 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1645 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1646 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001647 if (SS.isSet()) {
1648 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1649 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001650 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001651
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001652 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001653 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1654 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001655}
1656
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001657/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1658/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1659/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1660/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001661ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001662Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1663 LookupResult &R,
1664 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1665 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001666 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1667
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001668 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001669
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001670 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1671 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001672 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001673 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001674 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001675 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001676 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001677
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001678 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1679 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001680 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1681 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001682 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1683 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001684 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1685 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1686 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1687 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001688 }
1689
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001690 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001691 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1692 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001693 SS,
1694 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1695 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001696}
1697
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001698bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001699 const LookupResult &R,
1700 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001701 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1702 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1703 return false;
1704
1705 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001706 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001707 return false;
1708
1709 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001710 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001711 return false;
1712
1713 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1714 // normal lookup:
1715 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1716 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1717
1718 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1719 // -- a declaration of a class member
1720 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1721 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001722 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001723 return false;
1724
1725 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1726 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1727 // using-declaration
1728 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1729 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1730 // turn off ADL anyway).
1731 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1732 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1733 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1734 return false;
1735
1736 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1737 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1738 // template
1739 // And also for builtin functions.
1740 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1741 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1742
1743 // But also builtin functions.
1744 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1745 return false;
1746 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1747 return false;
1748 }
1749
1750 return true;
1751}
1752
1753
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001754/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1755/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1756/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1757/// will in fact be used.
1758static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1759 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1760 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1761 return true;
1762 }
1763
1764 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1765 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1766 return true;
1767 }
1768
1769 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1770 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1771 return true;
1772 }
1773
1774 return false;
1775}
1776
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001777ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001778Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001779 LookupResult &R,
1780 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001781 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1782 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001783 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001784 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1785 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001786
1787 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1788 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1789 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001790 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1791 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001792 return ExprError();
1793
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001794 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1795 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1796 // we've picked a target.
1797 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1798
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001799 bool Dependent
1800 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001801 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001802 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001803 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001804 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001805 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1806 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001807
1808 return Owned(ULE);
1809}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001810
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001811
1812/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001813ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001814Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001815 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1816 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001817 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001818 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1819 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001820
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001821 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001822 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1823 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001824
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001825 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1826 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1827 // a template argument list.
1828 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1829 << Template << SS.getRange();
1830 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1831 return ExprError();
1832 }
1833
1834 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1835 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1836 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001837 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001838 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001839 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001840 return ExprError();
1841 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001842
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001843 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1844 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1845 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1846 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001847 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001848 return ExprError();
1849
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001850 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1851 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001852 return ExprError();
1853
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001854 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1855 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1856 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1857 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001858 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001859 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1860 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1861 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001862 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001863 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001864 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1865 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1866 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1867 return ExprError();
1868 }
1869
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001870 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001871 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1872 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1873 return ExprError();
1874 }
1875
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001876 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001877 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001878 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001879 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001880 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001881 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1882 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001883 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001884
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001885 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001886 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001887 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1888 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001889 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001890 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1891 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1892 Expr *E = new (Context)
1893 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1894 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001895
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001896 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001897 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001898 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001899 SourceLocation(),
1900 Owned(E));
1901 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001902 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001903 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1904 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1905 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001906 }
1907 }
1908 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001909 }
1910 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1911 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001912
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001913 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1914 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001915}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001916
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001917ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001918 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001919 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001920
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001921 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001922 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001923 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1924 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1925 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001926 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001927
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001928 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1929 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001930
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001931 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001932 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1933 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001934 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001935 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001936 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001937 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001938
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001939 QualType ResTy;
1940 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1941 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1942 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001943 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001944
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001945 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001946 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001947 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1948 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001949 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001950}
1951
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001952ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001953 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001954 bool Invalid = false;
1955 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1956 if (Invalid)
1957 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001958
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001959 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1960 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001961 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001962 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001963
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001964 QualType Ty;
1965 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1966 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1967 else if (Literal.isWide())
1968 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001969 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1970 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001971 else
1972 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001973
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001974 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1975 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001976 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001977}
1978
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001979ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001980 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001981 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1982 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001983 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001984 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001985 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001986 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001987 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001988
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001989 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001990 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1991 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001992 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001993
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001994 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001995 bool Invalid = false;
1996 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1997 if (Invalid)
1998 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001999
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002000 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00002001 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00002002 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002003 return ExprError();
2004
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002005 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002006
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002007 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002008 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002009 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002010 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002011 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002012 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002013 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00002014 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002015
2016 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
2017
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002018 using llvm::APFloat;
2019 APFloat Val(Format);
2020
2021 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00002022
2023 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2024 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2025 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2026 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002027 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002028 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002029 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002030 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002031 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2032 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002033 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002034 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2035 }
2036
2037 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2038 << Ty
2039 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2040 }
2041
2042 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002043 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002044
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002045 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002046 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002047 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002048 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002049
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002050 // long long is a C99 feature.
2051 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002052 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002053 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2054
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002055 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002056 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002057
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002058 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2059 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2060 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002061 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2062 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002063 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002064 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002065 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2066 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002067
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002068 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2069 // be an unsigned int.
2070 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2071
2072 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002073 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002074 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2075 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002076 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002077
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002078 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2079 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2080 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2081 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002082 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002083 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002084 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002085 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002086 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002087 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002088
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002089 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002090 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002091 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002092
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002093 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2094 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2095 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2096 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002097 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002098 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002099 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002100 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002101 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002102 }
2103
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002104 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002105 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002106 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002107
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002108 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2109 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2110 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2111 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002112 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002113 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002114 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002115 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002116 }
2117 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002118
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002119 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2120 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002121 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002122 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002123 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002124 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002125 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002126
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002127 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2128 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002129 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002130 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002131 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002132
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002133 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2134 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002135 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002136 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002137
2138 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002139}
2140
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002141ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002142 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002143 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002144 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002145}
2146
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002147/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002148/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002149bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002150 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002151 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002152 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002153 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2154 return false;
2155
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002156 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2157 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2158 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2159 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2160 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2161 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2162
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002163 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002164 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002165 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002166 if (isSizeof)
2167 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2168 return false;
2169 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002170
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002171 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002172 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002173 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2174 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002175 return false;
2176 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002177
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002178 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002179 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2180 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002181 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002182
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002183 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002184 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002185 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002186 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2187 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002188 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002189
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002190 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002191}
2192
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002193static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2194 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002195 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002196
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002197 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002198 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2199 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002200
2201 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2202 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2203 return false;
2204
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002205 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002206 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002207 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002208 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002209
2210 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2211 // bit-field.
2212 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002213 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002214 return false;
2215
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002216 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002217}
2218
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002219/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002220ExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002221Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002222 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002223 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002224 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002225 return ExprError();
2226
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002227 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002228
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002229 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2230 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2231 return ExprError();
2232
2233 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002234 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002235 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2236 R.getEnd()));
2237}
2238
2239/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2240/// operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002241ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002242Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002243 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2244 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2245 bool isInvalid = false;
2246 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2247 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2248 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002249 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002250 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002251 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2252 isInvalid = true;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002253 } else if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
2254 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2255 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2256 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(PE.take(), OpLoc, isSizeOf, R);
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002257 } else {
2258 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2259 }
2260
2261 if (isInvalid)
2262 return ExprError();
2263
2264 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2265 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2266 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2267 R.getEnd()));
2268}
2269
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002270/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2271/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2272/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002273ExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002274Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2275 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002276 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002277 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002278
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002279 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002280 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002281 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002282 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002283 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002284
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002285 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002286 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002287 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2288
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002289 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002290}
2291
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002292QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002293 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2294 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002295
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002296 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002297 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002298 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002299
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002300 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2301 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2302 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002303
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002304 // Test for placeholders.
2305 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(V, Loc);
2306 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
2307 if (PR.take() != V) {
2308 V = PR.take();
2309 return CheckRealImagOperand(V, Loc, isReal);
2310 }
2311
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002312 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002313 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2314 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002315 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002316}
2317
2318
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002319
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002320ExprResult
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002321Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002322 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002323 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002324 switch (Kind) {
2325 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002326 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2327 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002328 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002329
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002330 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002331}
2332
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002333ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002334Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2335 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002336 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002337 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002338 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2339 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002340
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002341 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002342
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002343 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002344 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002345 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2346 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2347 }
2348
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002349 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002350 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002351 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2352 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2353 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002354 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002355 }
2356
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002357 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002358}
2359
2360
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002361ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002362Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2363 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2364 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2365 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002366
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002367 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002368 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2369 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2370 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002371
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002372 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002373
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002374 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002375 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002376 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002377 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002378 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2379 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002380 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2381 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2382 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2383 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002384 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002385 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2386 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002387 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002388 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002389 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002390 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2391 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002392 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002393 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002394 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002395 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2396 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2397 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002398 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002399 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002400 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2401 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2402 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2403 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002404 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002405 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002406 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002407
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002408 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2409 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002410 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2411 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002412 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002413 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2414 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2415 // force the promotion here.
2416 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2417 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002418 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002419 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002420 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2421
2422 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2423 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002424 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002425 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2426 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2427 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2428 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002429 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002430 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002431 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2432
2433 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2434 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002435 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002436 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002437 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2438 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002439 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002440 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002441 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002442 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2443 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002444
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002445 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002446 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2447 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002448 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2449
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002450 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002451 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2452 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002453 // incomplete types are not object types.
2454 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2455 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2456 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2457 return ExprError();
2458 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002459
Abramo Bagnara3aabb4b2010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002460 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2461 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2462 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2463 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2464 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002465 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002466 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2467 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002468 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002469
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002470 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002471 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002472 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2473 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2474 return ExprError();
2475 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002476
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002477 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002478 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002479}
2480
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002481QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002482CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002483 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002484 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002485 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2486 // see FIXME there.
2487 //
2488 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2489 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002490 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002491
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002492 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002493 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002494
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002495 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002496 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2497 // to be selected.
2498 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002499
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002500 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2501 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002502 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002503
2504 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2505 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002506 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002507 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2508 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002509 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002510 do
2511 compStr++;
2512 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002513 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002514 do
2515 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002516 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002517 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002518
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002519 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002520 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2521 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002522 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002523 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002524 return QualType();
2525 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002526
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002527 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2528 // operates on.
2529 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002530 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002531
2532 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002533 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002534
2535 while (*compStr) {
2536 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2537 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2538 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2539 return QualType();
2540 }
2541 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002542 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002543
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002544 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002545 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002546 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002547 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002548 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002549 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002550 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002551 if (HexSwizzle)
2552 CompSize--;
2553
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002554 if (CompSize == 1)
2555 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002556
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002557 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002558 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002559 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2560 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2561 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2562 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002563 }
2564 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002565}
2566
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002567static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002568 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002569 const Selector &Sel,
2570 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002571 if (Member)
2572 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
2573 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002574 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002575 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002576
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002577 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2578 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002579 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2580 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002581 return D;
2582 }
2583 return 0;
2584}
2585
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002586static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
2587 IdentifierInfo *Member,
2588 const Selector &Sel,
2589 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002590 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2591 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002592 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002593 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002594 if (Member)
2595 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
2596 GDecl = PD;
2597 break;
2598 }
2599 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002600 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002601 GDecl = OMD;
2602 break;
2603 }
2604 }
2605 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002606 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002607 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2608 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002609 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2610 Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002611 if (GDecl)
2612 return GDecl;
2613 }
2614 }
2615 return GDecl;
2616}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002617
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002618ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002619Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002620 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002621 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2622 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002623 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002624 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002625 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2626 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2627 //
2628 // T* t;
2629 // t.f;
2630 //
2631 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2632 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2633 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2634 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002635 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002636 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2637 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002638 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002639 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002640 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002641 return ExprError();
2642 }
2643 }
2644
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002645 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2646 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002647 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002648
2649 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2650 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002651 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002652 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002653 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002654 SS.getRange(),
2655 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002656 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002657}
2658
2659/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2660/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2661/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2662static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2663 Expr *BaseExpr,
2664 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002665 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002666 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002667 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2668 // diagnostics.
2669 if (!BaseExpr)
2670 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002671
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002672 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2673 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002674}
2675
2676// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2677// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2678// type. The restriction here is:
2679//
2680// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2681// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2682// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2683//
2684// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2685// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2686// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2687// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2688bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2689 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002690 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002691 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002692 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2693 if (!BaseRT) {
2694 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2695 // dependent.
2696 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2697 return false;
2698 }
2699 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002700
2701 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002702 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2703 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002704 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002705 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002706
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002707 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002708 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2709 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2710 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002711
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002712 if (!DC->isRecord())
2713 continue;
2714
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002715 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002716 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002717
2718 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2719 return false;
2720 }
2721
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002722 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002723 return true;
2724}
2725
2726static bool
2727LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2728 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002729 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2730 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002731 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2732 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002733 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002734 << BaseRange))
2735 return true;
2736
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002737 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2738 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2739 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2740
2741 bool MOUS;
2742 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2743 return false;
2744 }
2745
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002746 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2747 if (SS.isSet()) {
2748 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2749 // nested-name-specifier.
2750 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2751
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002752 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002753 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2754 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2755 return true;
2756 }
2757
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002758 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002759
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002760 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2761 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2762 << DC << SS.getRange();
2763 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002764 }
2765 }
2766
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002767 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2768 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002769
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002770 if (!R.empty())
2771 return false;
2772
2773 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2774 // for typos.
2775 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002776 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002777 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002778 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2779 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2780 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002781 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2782 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002783 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2784 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2785 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002786 return false;
2787 } else {
2788 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002789 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002790 }
2791
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002792 return false;
2793}
2794
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002795ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002796Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002797 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002798 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002799 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002800 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002801 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002802 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2803 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002804 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002805 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2806 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002807 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002808
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002809 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002810
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002811 // Implicit member accesses.
2812 if (!Base) {
2813 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2814 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2815 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2816 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002817 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002818 return ExprError();
2819
2820 // Explicit member accesses.
2821 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002822 ExprResult Result =
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002823 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002824 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002825
2826 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2827 Owned(Base);
2828 return ExprError();
2829 }
2830
2831 if (Result.get())
2832 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002833
2834 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2835 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002836 }
2837
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002838 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002839 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2840 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002841}
2842
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002843ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002844Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002845 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2846 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002847 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002848 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002849 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2850 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002851 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002852 if (IsArrow) {
2853 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2854 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2855 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002856 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002857
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002858 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002859 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2860 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2861 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002862
2863 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002864 return ExprError();
2865
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002866 if (R.empty()) {
2867 // Rederive where we looked up.
2868 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2869 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2870 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002871
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002872 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002873 << MemberName << DC
2874 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002875 return ExprError();
2876 }
2877
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002878 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2879 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2880 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2881 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2882 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2883 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2884 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2885 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2886 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2887 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002888 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002889 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002890 return ExprError();
2891
2892 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2893 // result.
2894 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002895 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002896 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002897 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002898 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002899
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002900 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2901 // pick a member.
2902 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2903
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002904 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2905 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2906 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002907 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2908 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002909 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002910 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002911 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002912
2913 return Owned(MemExpr);
2914 }
2915
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002916 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002917 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002918 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2919
2920 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2921
2922 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2923 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2924 // error cases.
2925 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2926 return ExprError();
2927
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002928 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2929 if (!BaseExpr) {
2930 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002931 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002932 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002933
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002934 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2935 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2936 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2937 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002938 }
2939
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002940 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2941 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2942 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2943 // explicitly qualified.
2944 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2945 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2946 }
2947
2948 // Check the use of this member.
2949 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2950 Owned(BaseExpr);
2951 return ExprError();
2952 }
2953
2954 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2955 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2956 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002957 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2958 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002959 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2960 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2961
2962 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2963 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2964 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2965 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2966 else {
2967 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2968 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2969 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2970
2971 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2972 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2973
2974 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2975 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2976 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2977 }
2978
2979 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002980 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002981 return ExprError();
2982 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002983 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2984 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002985 }
2986
2987 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2988 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2989 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002990 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002991 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2992 }
2993
2994 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2995 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2996 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002997 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002998 MemberFn->getType()));
2999 }
3000
3001 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3002 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3003 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003004 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3005 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003006 }
3007
3008 Owned(BaseExpr);
3009
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003010 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003011 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003012 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003013 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
3014 else
3015 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
3016 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003017
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003018 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
3019 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003020 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003021 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003022}
3023
3024/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
3025/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
3026/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
3027/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
3028/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
3029/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
3030/// an ordinary member expression.
3031///
3032/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3033/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003034ExprResult
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003035Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003036 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003037 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003038 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003039 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003040
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003041 // Perform default conversions.
3042 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003043
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003044 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003045 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3046
3047 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3048 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003049
3050 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003051 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003052 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3053 // call, and continue on.
3054 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3055 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3056 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3057 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3058 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003059 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3060 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003061 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3062 ->isRecordType()))) {
3063 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
Nick Lewyckyc60d6e72010-10-15 21:43:24 +00003064 Diag(BaseExpr->getExprLoc(), diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003065 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003066 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003067
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003068 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003069 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003070 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003071 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003072 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003073
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003074 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3075 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3076 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3077 }
3078 }
3079 }
3080
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003081 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3082 // use that.
3083 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003084 if (IsArrow) {
3085 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3086 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3087 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003088 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003089 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003090 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3091 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003092 }
3093 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003094 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3095 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3096 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3097 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003098 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003099 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003100 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003101
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003102 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3103 // use that.
3104 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3105 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3106 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3107 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3108 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003109 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003110 }
3111 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003112
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003113 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003114
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003115 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003116 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003117 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3118 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3119 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3120 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3121 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3122 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3123 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3124 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3125 // Check the use of this method.
3126 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3127 return ExprError();
3128 }
3129 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3130 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3131 Selector SetterSel =
3132 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3133 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3134 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3135 if (!Setter) {
3136 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3137 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003138 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003139 }
3140 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3141 if (!Setter)
3142 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003143
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003144 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3145 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003146
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003147 if (Getter || Setter) {
3148 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003149
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003150 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003151 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003152 else
3153 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3154 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3155 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003156 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003157 PType,
3158 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3159 }
3160 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3161 << MemberName << BaseType);
3162 }
3163 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003164
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003165 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3166 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3167 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003168 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003169 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003170
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003171 if (IsArrow) {
3172 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003173 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003174 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3175 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003176 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3177 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3178 // struct MyRecord foo;
3179 // foo->bar
3180 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3181 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3182 // by now.
3183 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3184 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003185 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003186 IsArrow = false;
3187 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003188 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3189 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3190 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003191 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003192 } else {
3193 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3194 // type *foo;
3195 // foo.bar
3196 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3197 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3198 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3199 // the appropriate pointer type
3200 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3201 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3202 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3203 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3204 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003205 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003206 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3207 IsArrow = true;
3208 }
3209 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003210 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003211
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003212 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003213 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003214 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003215 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003216 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003217 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003218 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003219
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003220 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3221 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003222 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003223 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003224 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003225 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3226 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3227 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3228 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003229 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3230
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003231 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003232 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003233
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003234 if (!IV) {
3235 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3236 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3237 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregord507d772010-10-20 03:06:34 +00003238 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false,
3239 IsArrow? CTC_ObjCIvarLookup
3240 : CTC_ObjCPropertyLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003241 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003242 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003243 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3244 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003245 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3246 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003247 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003248 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003249 } else {
3250 Res.clear();
3251 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003252 }
3253 }
3254
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003255 if (IV) {
3256 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3257 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3258 // error cases.
3259 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3260 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003261
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003262 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3263 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3264 return ExprError();
3265 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3266 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3267 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3268 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3269 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3270 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3271 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3272 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3273 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3274 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3275 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3276 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003277 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003278 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003279 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3280 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003281 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003282 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3283 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003284
3285 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3286 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003287 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003288 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003289 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003290 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3291 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003292 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003293 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003294 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003295
3296 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3297 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003298 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003299 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003300 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003301 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003302 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003303 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003304 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003305 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003306 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3307 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003308 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003309 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003310
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003311 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003312 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003313 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel,
3314 Context)) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003315 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3316 // Check the use of this declaration
3317 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3318 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003319
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003320 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003321 MemberLoc,
3322 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003323 }
3324 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3325 // Check the use of this method.
3326 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3327 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003328 Selector SetterSel =
3329 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3330 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3331 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3332 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, /*Property id*/0,
3333 SetterSel, Context))
3334 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3335 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3336 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(OMD, PType,
3337 SMD,
3338 MemberLoc,
3339 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003340 }
3341 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003342
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003343 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003344 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003345 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003346
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003347 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3348 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003349 if (!IsArrow)
3350 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3351 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003352 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc,
3353 SourceLocation(), QualType(), false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003354
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003355 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003356 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003357 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3358 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003359 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003360 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003361 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003362
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003363 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003364 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003365 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003366 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3367 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003368 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003369 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003370 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003371 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003372
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003373 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3374 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3375
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003376 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003377}
3378
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003379/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3380/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3381/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3382/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3383/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3384///
3385/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3386/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3387/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3388/// only be called
3389/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3390/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3391/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003392ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003393 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3394 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003395 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003396 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003397 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003398 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3399 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3400 return ExprError();
3401
3402 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3403
3404 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003405 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003406 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3407 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003408 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003409
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003410 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003411 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3412
3413 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3414 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3415 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3416
3417 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003418 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003419 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3420 Base = Result.take();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003421
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003422 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3423 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003424 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003425 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3426 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003427 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003428 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003429 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003430 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3431 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003432
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003433 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3434 Owned(Base);
3435 return ExprError();
3436 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003437
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003438 if (Result.get()) {
3439 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3440 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3441 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3442 // call now.
3443 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3444 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003445 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003446
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003447 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003448 }
3449
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003450 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003451 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3452 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003453 }
3454
3455 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003456}
3457
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003458ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003459 FunctionDecl *FD,
3460 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3461 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003462 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003463 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3464 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003465 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003466 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003467 return ExprError();
3468 }
3469
3470 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3471 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003472
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003473 // Instantiate the expression.
3474 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3475 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003476
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003477 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3478 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3479 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3480 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003481
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003482 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3483 if (Result.isInvalid())
3484 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003485
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003486 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3487 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003488 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003489 InitializationKind Kind
3490 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3491 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3492 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003493
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003494 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3495 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3496 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3497 if (Result.isInvalid())
3498 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003499
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003500 // Build the default argument expression.
3501 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3502 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003503 }
3504
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003505 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3506 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3507 // be properly destroyed.
3508 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3509 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003510 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3511 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3512 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3513 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3514 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3515 }
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003516
3517 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003518 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3519 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003520 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003521 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003522}
3523
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003524/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3525/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3526/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3527/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3528/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3529/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003530bool
3531Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003532 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003533 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003534 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3535 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003536 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003537 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3538 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003539 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003540
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003541 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3542 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3543 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3544 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3545 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003546 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003547 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003548 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003549 }
3550
3551 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3552 // them.
3553 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3554 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3555 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3556 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003557 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003558 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003559 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3560 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3561 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003562 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003563 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003564 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003565 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003566 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003567 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003568 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3569 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3570 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3571 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3572 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003573 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003574 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003575 if (Invalid)
3576 return true;
3577 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3578 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3579 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003580
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003581 return false;
3582}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003583
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003584bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3585 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3586 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3587 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3588 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3589 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003590 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003591 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3592 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3593 bool Invalid = false;
3594 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3595 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3596 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3597 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003598 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003599 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003600 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003601
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003602 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003603 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3604 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003605
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003606 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3607 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003608 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003609 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003610 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003611
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003612 // Pass the argument
3613 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3614 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3615 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003616
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003617 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003618 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3619 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003620 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003621 SourceLocation(),
3622 Owned(Arg));
3623 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3624 return true;
3625
3626 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003627 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003628 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003629
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003630 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003631 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003632 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3633 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003634
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003635 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003636 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003637 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003638 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003639
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003640 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003641 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003642 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003643 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003644 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003645 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003646 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003647 }
3648 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003649 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003650}
3651
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003652/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003653/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3654/// locations.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003655ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003656Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003657 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003658 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003659
3660 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003661 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003662 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3663 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003664
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003665 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003666
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003667 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003668 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3669 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3670 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3671 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3672 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003673 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003674 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3675 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003676
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003677 NumArgs = 0;
3678 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003679
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003680 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3681 RParenLoc));
3682 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003683
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003684 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003685 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003686 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3687 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003688 bool Dependent = false;
3689 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3690 Dependent = true;
3691 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3692 Dependent = true;
3693
3694 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003695 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003696 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3697
3698 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3699 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3700 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003701 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003702
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003703 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3704
3705 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3706 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3707 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3708 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3709 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3710 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3711 // method template.
3712 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003713 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3714 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003715 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003716
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003717 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003718 RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003719 }
3720
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003721 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003722 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003723 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003724 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003725 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003726 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003727 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003728
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003729 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003730 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003731 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3732 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003733 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3734 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003735 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003736
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003737 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3738 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3739 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3740 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003741
3742 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3743 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003744 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003745 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003746
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003747 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003748 RParenLoc))
3749 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003750
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003751 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003752 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003753 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003754 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3755 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003756 }
3757 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003758 }
3759
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003760 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003761 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003762 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003763
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003764 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003765 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3766 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003767 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003768 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003769 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003770
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003771 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3772 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3773 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3774
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003775 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3776}
3777
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003778/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3779/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003780/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3781/// block-pointer type.
3782///
3783/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003784ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003785Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3786 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3787 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3788 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3789 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3790
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003791 // Promote the function operand.
3792 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3793
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003794 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3795 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003796 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3797 Args, NumArgs,
3798 Context.BoolTy,
3799 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003800
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003801 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3802 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3803 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3804 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003805 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003806 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003807 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3808 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003809 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003810 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003811 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003812 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003813 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003814 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003815 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3816 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3817
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003818 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003819 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003820 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003821 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003822 return ExprError();
3823
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003824 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003825 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003826
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003827 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003828 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003829 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003830 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003831 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003832 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003833
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003834 if (FDecl) {
3835 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3836 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3837 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003838 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Douglas Gregor8e09a722010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003839 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
3840 = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3841 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size()))
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003842 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3843 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003844 }
Douglas Gregor8e09a722010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003845
3846 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
3847 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
3848 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
3849 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003850 }
3851
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003852 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003853 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3854 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Douglas Gregor8e09a722010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003855
3856 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumArgs()) {
3857 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3858 Arg->getType(),
3859 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3860 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
3861 return ExprError();
3862
3863 InitializedEntity Entity
3864 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
3865 Proto->getArgType(i));
3866 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3867 SourceLocation(),
3868 Owned(Arg));
3869 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3870 return true;
3871
3872 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
3873
3874 } else {
3875 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
3876
3877 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3878 Arg->getType(),
3879 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3880 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
3881 return ExprError();
3882 }
3883
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003884 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003885 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003886 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003887
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003888 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3889 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003890 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3891 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003892
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003893 // Check for sentinels
3894 if (NDecl)
3895 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003896
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003897 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003898 if (FDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003899 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003900 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003901
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003902 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003903 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003904 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003905 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003906 return ExprError();
3907 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003908
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003909 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003910}
3911
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003912ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003913Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003914 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003915 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003916 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003917 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003918
3919 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3920 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3921 if (!TInfo)
3922 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3923
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003924 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003925}
3926
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003927ExprResult
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003928Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003929 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003930 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003931
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003932 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003933 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003934 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3935 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003936 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3937 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003938 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003939 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003940 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003941 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003942
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003943 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003944 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003945 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003946 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003947 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003948 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003949 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003950 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003951 &literalType);
3952 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003953 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003954 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003955
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003956 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003957 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003958 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003959 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003960 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003961
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003962 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003963 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003964}
3965
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003966ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003967Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003968 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3969 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003970 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003971
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003972 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003973 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003974
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003975 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3976 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003977 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003978 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003979}
3980
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003981static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003982 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003983 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003984 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003985
3986 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3987 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003988 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003989 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3990 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003991 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003992 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003993 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003994
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003995 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3996 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003997 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003998 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003999 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004000 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004001 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004002 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004003
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004004 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
4005 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004006 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004007 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004008 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004009 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004010
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004011 // FIXME: Assert here.
4012 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004013 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004014}
4015
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004016/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00004017bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004018 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004019 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00004020 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004021 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004022 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
4023 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004024
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004025 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004026
4027 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
4028 // type needs to be scalar.
4029 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
4030 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004031 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004032 return false;
4033 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004034
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00004035 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
4036 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
4037 return true;
4038
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004039 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004040 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004041 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
4042 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004043 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004044 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
4045 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004046 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004047 return false;
4048 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004049
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004050 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004051 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004052 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004053 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004054 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004055 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004056 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara5d3e7242010-10-07 21:20:44 +00004057 castExpr->getType()) &&
4058 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004059 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
4060 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4061 break;
4062 }
4063 }
4064 if (Field == FieldEnd)
4065 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4066 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004067 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004068 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004069 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004070
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004071 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4072 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4073 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4074 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004075
4076 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004077 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004078 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4079 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004080 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004081 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004082
4083 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004084 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004085
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004086 if (castType->isVectorType())
4087 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4088 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4089 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4090
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004091 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4092 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004093
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004094 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004095 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004096 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004097 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004098 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4099 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4100 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4101 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004102 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004103 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4104 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4105 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004106 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004107
4108 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004109
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004110 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004111 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4112
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004113 return false;
4114}
4115
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004116bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004117 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004118 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004119
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004120 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004121 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004122 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004123 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004124 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004125 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004126 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004127 } else
4128 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004129 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004130 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004131
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004132 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004133 return false;
4134}
4135
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004136bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004137 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004138 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004139
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004140 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004141
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004142 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4143 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004144 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4145 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4146 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4147 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004148 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004149 return false;
4150 }
4151
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004152 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004153 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4154 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004155 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4156 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4157 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4158 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004159
4160 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4161 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4162 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004163
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004164 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004165 return false;
4166}
4167
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004168ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004169Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004170 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4171 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004172 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004173
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004174 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4175 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4176 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004177 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004178
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004179 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4180 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004181 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004182 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004183
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004184 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004185}
4186
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004187ExprResult
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004188Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004189 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004190 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004191 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004192 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004193 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004194 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004195
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004196 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004197 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004198 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4199 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004200}
4201
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004202/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4203/// of comma binary operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004204ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004205Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004206 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4207 if (!E)
4208 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004209
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004210 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004211
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004212 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004213 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4214 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004215
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004216 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4217
4218 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004219}
4220
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004221ExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004222Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004223 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004224 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004225 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004226 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004227 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004228
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004229 // Check for an altivec literal,
4230 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004231 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4232 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4233 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4234 return ExprError();
4235 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004236 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4237 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4238 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4239 }
4240 else
4241 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4242 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004243
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004244 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4245 // then handle it as such.
4246 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004247 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4248 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4249 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4250
4251 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4252 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004253 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4254 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004255 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4256 E->setType(Ty);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004257 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004258 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004259 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004260 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004261 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004262 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4263 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004264 }
4265}
4266
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004267ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004268 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004269 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004270 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004271 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4272 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004273 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4274 Expr *expr;
4275 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4276 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4277 else
4278 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004279 return Owned(expr);
4280}
4281
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004282/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4283/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004284/// C99 6.5.15
4285QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004286 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004287 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004288 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4289 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004290 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004291
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004292 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004293 if (SAVE) {
4294 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4295 }
4296 else
4297 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004298 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4299 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4300 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4301 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004302
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004303 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004304 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begemanabb5a732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004305 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4306 // Throw an error if its not either.
4307 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4308 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4309 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4310 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4311 << CondTy;
4312 return QualType();
4313 }
4314 }
4315 else {
4316 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4317 << CondTy;
4318 return QualType();
4319 }
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004320 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004321
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004322 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004323 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4324 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004325
Nate Begemanabb5a732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004326 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4327 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4328 // built in select.
4329 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4330 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4331 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4332 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4333 << CondTy;
4334 return QualType();
4335 }
4336 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4337 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4338 << CondTy;
4339 return QualType();
4340 }
4341 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4342 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4343 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4344 }
4345
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004346 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4347 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004348 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4349 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4350 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004351 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004352
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004353 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4354 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004355 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4356 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004357 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004358 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004359 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004360 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004361 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004362 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004363
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004364 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004365 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004366 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4367 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4368 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4369 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4370 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4371 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4372 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004373 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4374 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004375 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004376 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004377 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4378 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004379 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004380 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004381 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004382 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004383 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004384 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004385 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004386 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004387 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004388 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004389 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004390
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004391 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4392 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4393 QuestionLoc);
4394 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4395 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004396
4397
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004398 // Handle block pointer types.
4399 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4400 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4401 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4402 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004403 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4404 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004405 return destType;
4406 }
4407 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004408 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004409 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004410 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004411 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4412 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4413 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004414 return LHSTy;
4415 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004416 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004417 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4418 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004419
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004420 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4421 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004422 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004423 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004424 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4425 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4426 // to get a consistent AST.
4427 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004428 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4429 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004430 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004431 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004432 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004433 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4434 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004435 return LHSTy;
4436 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004437
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004438 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4439 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4440 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004441 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4442 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004443
4444 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4445 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4446 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004447 QualType destPointee
4448 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004449 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004450 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004451 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004452 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004453 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004454 return destType;
4455 }
4456 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004457 QualType destPointee
4458 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004459 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004460 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004461 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004462 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004463 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004464 return destType;
4465 }
4466
4467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4468 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4469 return LHSTy;
4470 }
4471 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4472 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4473 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4474 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4475 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4476 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4477 // to get a consistent AST.
4478 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004479 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4480 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004481 return incompatTy;
4482 }
4483 // The pointer types are compatible.
4484 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4485 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4486 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4487 // type.
4488 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4489 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004490 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4491 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004492 return LHSTy;
4493 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004494
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004495 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4496 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4497 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4498 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004499 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004500 return RHSTy;
4501 }
4502 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4503 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4504 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004505 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004506 return LHSTy;
4507 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004508
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004509 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004510 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4511 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004512 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004513}
4514
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004515/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4516/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4517QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4518 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4519 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4520 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004521
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004522 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4523 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4524 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4525 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4526 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004527 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004528 return LHSTy;
4529 }
4530 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4531 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004532 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004533 return RHSTy;
4534 }
4535 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4536 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4537 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004538 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004539 return LHSTy;
4540 }
4541 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4542 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004543 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004544 return RHSTy;
4545 }
4546 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4547 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4548 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004549 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004550 return LHSTy;
4551 }
4552 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4553 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004554 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004555 return RHSTy;
4556 }
4557 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4558 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004559
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004560 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4561 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4562 return LHSTy;
4563 }
4564 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4565 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4566 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004567
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004568 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4569 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4570 // type. This allows
4571 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4572 // where B is a subclass of A.
4573 //
4574 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4575 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4576 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4577 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004578
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004579 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4580 // It could return the composite type.
4581 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4582 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4583 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4584 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4585 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4586 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4587 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4588 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4589 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4590 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4591 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4592 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4593 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4594 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004595 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004596 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4597 ;
4598 else {
4599 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4600 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4601 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4602 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004603 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4604 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004605 return incompatTy;
4606 }
4607 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004608 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4609 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004610 return compositeType;
4611 }
4612 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4613 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4614 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4615 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4616 QualType destPointee
4617 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4618 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4619 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004620 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004621 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004622 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004623 return destType;
4624 }
4625 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4626 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4627 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4628 QualType destPointee
4629 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4630 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4631 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004632 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004633 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004634 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004635 return destType;
4636 }
4637 return QualType();
4638}
4639
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004640/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004641/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004642ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004643 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004644 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4645 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004646 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4647 // was the condition.
4648 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004649 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4650 if (isLHSNull) {
4651 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4652 }
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004653
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004654 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4655 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004656 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004657 return ExprError();
4658
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004659 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004660 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4661 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4662 result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004663}
4664
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004665// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004666// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004667// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4668// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4669// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004670Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004671Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004672 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004673
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004674 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4675 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4676 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4677 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4678 return Compatible;
4679 }
4680
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004681 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004682 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4683 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004684
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004685 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004686 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4687 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004688
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004689 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004690
4691 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4692 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4693 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004694 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004695 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004696 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004697
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004698 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4699 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004700 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004701 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004702 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004703 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004704
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004705 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004706 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4707 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004708 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004709
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004710 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004711 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004712 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004713
4714 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004715 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4716 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004717 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004718 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004719 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004720 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4721 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4722 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4723 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4724 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4725 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004726 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004727 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004728 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004729 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004730
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004731 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004732 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004733 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004734 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004735
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004736 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4737 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4738 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4739 // warning can be disabled.
4740 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4741 return ConvTy;
4742 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4743 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004744
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004745 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4746 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4747 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4748 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4749 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4750 do {
4751 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4752 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004753
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004754 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4755 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4756 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004757
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004758 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004759 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004760 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004761
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004762 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004763 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004764 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004765 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004766}
4767
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004768/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4769/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4770/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4771// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004772Sema::AssignConvertType
4773Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004774 QualType rhsType) {
4775 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004776
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004777 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004778 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4779 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004780
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004781 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4782 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4783 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004784
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004785 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004786
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004787 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004788 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004789 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004790
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004791 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4792 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4793 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4794 }
4795 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004796 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004797 return ConvTy;
4798}
4799
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004800/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4801/// for assignment compatibility.
4802Sema::AssignConvertType
4803Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004804 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4805 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004806 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4807 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004808 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004809 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004810 }
4811 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4812 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004813 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4814 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004815 return IncompatiblePointer;
4816 return Compatible;
4817 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004818 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004819 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004820 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004821 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4822 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4823 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4824 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4825 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4826 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004827
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004828 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4829 return Compatible;
4830 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4831 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004832 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004833}
4834
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004835/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4836/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004837/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4838///
4839/// int a, *pint;
4840/// short *pshort;
4841/// struct foo *pfoo;
4842///
4843/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4844/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4845/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4846/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4847///
4848/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004849/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004850///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004851Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004852Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004853 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4854 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004855 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4856 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004857
4858 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004859 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004860
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004861 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4862 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4863 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4864 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4865 return Compatible;
4866 }
4867
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004868 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4869 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4870 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4871 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4872 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4873 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4874 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004875 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004876 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004877 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004878 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004879 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004880 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4881 // to the same ExtVector type.
4882 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4883 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4884 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004885 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004886 return Compatible;
4887 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004888
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004889 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004890 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4891 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4892 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4893 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4894 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4895 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004896 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004897
4898 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4899 // vector type and vice versa
4900 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4901 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004902 }
4903 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004904 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004905
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004906 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4907 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004908 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004909
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004910 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004911 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004912 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004913
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004914 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004915 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004916
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004917 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004918 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004919 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4920 return Compatible;
4921 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004922 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004923 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4924 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004925 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004926
4927 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004928 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004929 return Compatible;
4930 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004931 return Incompatible;
4932 }
4933
4934 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4935 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004936 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004937
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004938 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004939 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004940 return Compatible;
4941
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004942 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4943 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004944
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004945 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004946 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004947 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004948 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004949 return Incompatible;
4950 }
4951
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004952 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4953 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4954 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004955
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004956 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004957 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004958 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4959 return Compatible;
4960 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004961 }
4962 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004963 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004964 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004965 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004966 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4967 return Compatible;
4968 }
4969 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4970 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4971 return Compatible;
4972 return Incompatible;
4973 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004974 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004975 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004976 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4977 return Compatible;
4978
4979 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004980 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004981
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004982 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004983 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004984
4985 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004986 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004987 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004988 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004989 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004990 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4991 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4992 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4993 return Compatible;
4994
4995 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4996 return PointerToInt;
4997
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004998 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004999 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005000 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5001 return Compatible;
5002 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005003 }
5004 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005005 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005006 return Compatible;
5007 return Incompatible;
5008 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005009
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005010 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005011 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005012 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00005013 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005014 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00005015}
5016
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005017/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
5018/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005019static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005020 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
5021 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
5022 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00005023 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00005024 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005025 SourceLocation());
5026 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
5027 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
5028
5029 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
5030 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005031 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00005032 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005033 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005034}
5035
5036Sema::AssignConvertType
5037Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
5038 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
5039
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005040 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005041 // transparent_union GCC extension.
5042 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005043 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005044 return Incompatible;
5045
5046 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
5047 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
5048 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
5049 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005050 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
5051 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005052 it != itend; ++it) {
5053 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
5054 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
5055 // 1) void pointer
5056 // 2) null pointer constant
5057 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005058 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005059 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005060 InitField = *it;
5061 break;
5062 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005063
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005064 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005065 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005066 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005067 InitField = *it;
5068 break;
5069 }
5070 }
5071
5072 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
5073 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar60785eb2010-09-17 23:21:43 +00005074 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005075 InitField = *it;
5076 break;
5077 }
5078 }
5079
5080 if (!InitField)
5081 return Incompatible;
5082
5083 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5084 return Compatible;
5085}
5086
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005087Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005088Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005089 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5090 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5091 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5092 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5093 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005094 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005095 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005096 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005097 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005098 }
5099
5100 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5101 // structures.
5102 }
5103
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005104 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5105 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005106 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5107 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005108 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005109 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005110 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005111 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005112 return Compatible;
5113 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005114
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005115 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005116 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005117 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005118 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005119 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005120 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005121 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005122 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005123
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005124 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5125 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005126
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005127 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5128 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005129 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5130 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5131 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5132 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005133 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005134 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005135 CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005136 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005137}
5138
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005139QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005140 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005141 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005142 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005143 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00005144}
5145
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005146QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005147 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005148 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005149 QualType lhsType =
5150 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5151 QualType rhsType =
5152 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005153
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005154 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005155 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005156 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005157
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005158 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5159 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005160 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005161 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005162 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005163 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005164 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005165 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005166 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005167 return lhsType;
5168 }
5169
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005170 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005171 return rhsType;
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005172 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5173 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5174 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5175 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5176 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5177 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005178 }
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005179 }
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005180 }
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005181 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005182
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005183 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5184 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5185 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005186 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005187 return rhsType;
5188 }
5189
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005190 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5191 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5192 bool swapped = false;
5193 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5194 swapped = true;
5195 std::swap(rex, lex);
5196 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5197 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005198
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005199 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005200 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005201 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005202 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005203 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005204 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005205 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5206 return lhsType;
5207 }
5208 }
5209 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5210 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5211 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005212 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005213 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5214 return lhsType;
5215 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005216 }
5217 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005218
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005219 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005220 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005221 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005222 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005223 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005224}
5225
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005226QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5227 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005228 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005229 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005230
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005231 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005232
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005233 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5234 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5235 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005236
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005237 // Check for division by zero.
5238 if (isDiv &&
5239 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005240 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005241 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005242
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005243 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005244}
5245
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005246QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005247 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005248 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005249 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5250 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005251 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5252 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5253 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005254
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005255 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005256
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005257 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5258 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005259
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005260 // Check for remainder by zero.
5261 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005262 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5263 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005264
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005265 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005266}
5267
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005268QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005269 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005270 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5271 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5272 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5273 return compType;
5274 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005275
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005276 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005277
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005278 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005279 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5280 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5281 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005282 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005283 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005284
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005285 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5286 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005287 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005288 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5289
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005290 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005291
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005292 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005293 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005294
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005295 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5296 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005297 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5298 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005299 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005300 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005301 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005302
5303 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5304 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5305 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005306 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005307 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5308 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5309 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5310 return QualType();
5311 }
5312
5313 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5314 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5315 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005316 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005317 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005318 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005319 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005320 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5321 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005322 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5323 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005324 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005325 return QualType();
5326 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005327 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005328 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005329 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5330 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5331 return QualType();
5332 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005333
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005334 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005335 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5336 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5337 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5338 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5339 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005340 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005341 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5342 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005343 return PExp->getType();
5344 }
5345 }
5346
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005347 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005348}
5349
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005350// C99 6.5.6
5351QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005352 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5353 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5354 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5355 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5356 return compType;
5357 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005358
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005359 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005360
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005361 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005362
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005363 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005364 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5365 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005366 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005367 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005368 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005369
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005370 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005371 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005372 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005373
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005374 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005375
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005376 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5377 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5378 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5379 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5380 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5381 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5382 return QualType();
5383 }
5384
5385 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5386 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5387 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5388 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5389 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005390 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005391 return QualType();
5392 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005393
5394 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5395 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5396 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005397 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005398 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005399 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005400 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005401 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005402
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005403 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005404 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005405 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5406 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5407 return QualType();
5408 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005409
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005410 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005411 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5412 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5413 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5414 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5415 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5416 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005417 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005418 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5419
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005420 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005421 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005422 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005423
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005424 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005425 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005426 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005427
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005428 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5429 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5430 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5431 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5432 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5433 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5434 return QualType();
5435 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005436
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005437 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5438 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5439 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5440 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005441 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005442 return QualType();
5443 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005444
5445 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5446 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5447 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5448 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5449 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005450 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5451 << rex->getSourceRange()
5452 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005453 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005454
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005455 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5456 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5457 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5458 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5459 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5460 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5461 return QualType();
5462 }
5463 } else {
5464 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5465 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5466 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5467 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5468 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5469 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5470 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5471 return QualType();
5472 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005473 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005474
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005475 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5476 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5477 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5478 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5479 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005480 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005481 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005482
5483 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005484 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5485 }
5486 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005487
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005488 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005489}
5490
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005491static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5492 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5493 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5494 return false;
5495}
5496
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005497// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005498QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005499 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005500 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005501 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5502 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005503 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005504
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005505 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5506 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5507 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5508 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5509 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5510 }
5511
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005512 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5513 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5514 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5515
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005516 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5517 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005518 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5519 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5520 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5521 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5522 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005523 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005524 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005525 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005526
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005527 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005528
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005529 // Sanity-check shift operands
5530 llvm::APSInt Right;
5531 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005532 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5533 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005534 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005535 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5536 else {
5537 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5538 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5539 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5540 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5541 }
5542 }
5543
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005544 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005545 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005546}
5547
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005548static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5549 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5550 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5551 return true;
5552 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5553 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5554 }
5555 return false;
5556}
5557
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005558// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005559QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005560 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005561 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005562
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005563 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005564 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005565 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005566
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005567 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5568 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005569
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005570 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenek853734e2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005571 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5572 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5573 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005574 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5575 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5576 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005577 //
5578 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5579 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5580 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5581 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5582 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5583 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005584 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5585 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005586 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005587 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenek853734e2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005588 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005589 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005590 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5591 << 0 // self-
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005592 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5593 || Opc == BO_LE
5594 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005595 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5596 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5597 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5598 // what is it always going to eval to?
5599 char always_evals_to;
5600 switch(Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005601 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005602 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5603 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005604 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005605 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5606 break;
5607 default:
5608 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5609 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5610 break;
5611 }
5612 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5613 << 1 // array
5614 << always_evals_to);
5615 }
5616 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005617 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005618
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005619 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5620 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5621 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5622 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005623
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005624 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5625 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005626 Expr *literalString = 0;
5627 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005628 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005629 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005630 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005631 literalString = lex;
5632 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005633 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5634 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005635 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005636 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005637 literalString = rex;
5638 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5639 }
5640
5641 if (literalString) {
5642 std::string resultComparison;
5643 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005644 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5645 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5646 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5647 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5648 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5649 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005650 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5651 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005652
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005653 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5654 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5655 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005656 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005657 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005658 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005659
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005660 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5661 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5662 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5663 else {
5664 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5665 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5666 }
5667
5668 lType = lex->getType();
5669 rType = rex->getType();
5670
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005671 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005672 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005673
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005674 if (isRelational) {
5675 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005676 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005677 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005678 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005679 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005680 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005681
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005682 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005683 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005684 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005685
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005686 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005687 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005688 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005689 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005690
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005691 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5692 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005693 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005694 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005695 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005696 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005697 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005698
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005699 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005700 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5701 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005702 if (!isRelational &&
5703 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5704 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5705 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005706 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5707 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005708 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5709 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005710 Diag(Loc,
5711 isSFINAEContext()?
5712 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5713 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005714 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005715
5716 if (isSFINAEContext())
5717 return QualType();
5718
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005719 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005720 return ResultTy;
5721 }
5722 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005723 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5724 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5725 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5726 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5727 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5728 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005729 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005730 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005731 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005732 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005733 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005734 if (T.isNull()) {
5735 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5736 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5737 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005738 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005739 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005740 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005741 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005742 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005743 }
5744
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005745 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5746 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005747 return ResultTy;
5748 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005749 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5750 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5751 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5752 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5753 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5754 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5755 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5756 }
5757 } else if (!isRelational &&
5758 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5759 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5760 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5761 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5762 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5763 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5764 }
5765 } else {
5766 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005767 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005768 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005769 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005770 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005771 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005772 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005773 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005774
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005775 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005776 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005777 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005778 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005779 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5780 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005781 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5782 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005783 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5784 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005785 return ResultTy;
5786 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005787 if (LHSIsNull &&
5788 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5789 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005790 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5791 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005792 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5793 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005794 return ResultTy;
5795 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005796
5797 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005798 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005799 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5800 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005801 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5802 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5803 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5804 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5805 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5806 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5807 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5808 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005809 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005810 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005811 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005812 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005813 if (T.isNull()) {
5814 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005815 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005816 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005817 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005818 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005819 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005820 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005821 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005822 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005823
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005824 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5825 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005826 return ResultTy;
5827 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005828
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005829 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005830 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5831 return ResultTy;
5832 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005833
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005834 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005835 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005836 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5837 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005838
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005839 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005840 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005841 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005842 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005843 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005844 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005845 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005846 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005847 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005848 if (!isRelational
5849 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5850 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005851 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005852 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005853 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005854 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005855 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5856 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5857 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005858 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005859 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005860 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005861 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005862
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005863 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005864 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005865 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5866 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005867 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005868 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005869 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005870 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005871
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005872 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5873 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005874 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005875 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005876 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005877 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005878 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005879 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005880 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005881 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005882 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5883 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005884 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005885 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005886 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005887 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005888 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5889 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005890 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005891 bool isError = false;
5892 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5893 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5894 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005895 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005896 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005897 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005898 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5899 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5900 isError = true;
5901 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005902 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005903
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005904 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005905 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005906 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005907 if (isError)
5908 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005909 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005910
5911 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005912 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005913 else
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005914 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005915 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005916 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005917
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005918 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005919 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5920 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005921 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005922 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005923 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005924 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5925 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005926 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005927 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005928 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005929 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005930}
5931
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005932/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005933/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005934/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5935/// types.
5936QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005937 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005938 bool isRelational) {
5939 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5940 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005941 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005942 if (vType.isNull())
5943 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005944
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005945 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5946 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005947
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005948 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5949 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5950 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005951 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005952 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5953 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5954 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005955 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5956 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5957 << 0 // self-
5958 << 2 // "a constant"
5959 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005960 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005961
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005962 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005963 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5964 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005965 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005966 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005967
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005968 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5969 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5970 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005971 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005972 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005973
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005974 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005975 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005976 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005977 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005978 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005979 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5980
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005981 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005982 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005983 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5984}
5985
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005986inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005987 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005988 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5989 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5990 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5991 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5992
5993 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5994 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005995
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005996 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005997
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005998 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
5999 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006000 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006001 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006002}
6003
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006004inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006005 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
6006
6007 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
6008 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
6009 // is a constant.
6010 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00006011 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00006012 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006013 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
6014 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
6015 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
6016 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
6017 Expr::EvalResult Result;
6018 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
6019 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
6020 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
6021 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006022 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
6023 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006024 }
6025 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006026
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006027 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6028 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6029 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006030
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006031 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
6032 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006033
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006034 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00006035 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006036
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006037 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
6038 // non-overloadable operands.
6039
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006040 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
6041 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006042 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
6043 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
6044 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006045 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006046
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006047 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
6048 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
6049 // The result is a bool.
6050 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006051}
6052
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006053/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
6054/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
6055/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
6056///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006057static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006058 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6059 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
6060 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00006061 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->isSuperReceiver() ?
6062 PropExpr->getSuperType() :
6063 PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
6064
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006065 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006066 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6067 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6068 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6069 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006070 }
6071 }
6072 return false;
6073}
6074
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006075/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6076/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6077static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006078 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006079 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006080 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006081 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6082 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006083 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6084 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006085
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006086 unsigned Diag = 0;
6087 bool NeedType = false;
6088 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006089 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006090 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006091 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6092 NeedType = true;
6093 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006094 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006095 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6096 NeedType = true;
6097 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006098 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006099 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6100 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006101 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6102 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006103 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006104 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6105 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006106 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6107 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006108 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6109 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006110 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006111 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006112 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006113 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006114 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6115 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006116 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006117 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6118 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006119 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6120 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6121 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006122 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6123 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6124 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006125 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6126 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6127 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006128 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006129
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006130 SourceRange Assign;
6131 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6132 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006133 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006134 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006135 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006136 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006137 return true;
6138}
6139
6140
6141
6142// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006143QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6144 SourceLocation Loc,
6145 QualType CompoundType) {
6146 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6147 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006148 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006149
6150 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6151 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006152 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006153 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006154 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006155 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006156 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006157 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006158 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6159 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6160 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006161 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006162 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006163 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006164 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006165
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006166 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6167 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6168 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006169 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006170 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6171 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6172 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006173 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6174 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006175 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006176 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006177 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6178 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6179 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006180 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6181 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006182 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006183 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006184 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006185 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006186 }
6187 } else {
6188 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006189 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006190 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006191
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006192 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006193 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006194 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006195
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006196
6197 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6198 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6199 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6200 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6201 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6202 // check.
6203 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006204 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006205 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6206 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6207 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6208 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6209 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6210 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6211 }
6212
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006213 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6214 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006215 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006216 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6217 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006218 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006219 // operand.
John McCall01cbf2d2010-10-12 02:19:57 +00006220 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6221 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006222}
6223
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006224// C99 6.5.17
6225QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006226 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6227
John McCall73d36182010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006228 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
6229 // operands, but not unary promotions.
6230 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6231 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6232 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS);
6233 if (!LHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6234 RequireCompleteType(Loc, LHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006235
John McCall73d36182010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006236 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
6237 if (!RHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6238 RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
6239 }
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006240
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006241 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006242}
6243
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006244/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6245/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006246QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006247 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006248 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6249 return Context.DependentTy;
6250
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006251 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6252 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006253
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006254 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6255 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6256 if (!isInc) {
6257 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6258 return QualType();
6259 }
6260 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6261 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6262 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006263 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006264 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6265 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006266
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006267 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006268 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006269 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6270 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6271 << Op->getSourceRange();
6272 return QualType();
6273 }
6274
6275 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006276 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006277 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006278 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6279 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6280 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6281 return QualType();
6282 }
6283
6284 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006285 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006286 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006287 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006288 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006289 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006290 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006291 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006292 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006293 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6294 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6295 return QualType();
6296 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006297 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006298 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6299 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006300 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006301 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6302 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6303 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6304 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc, isInc, isPrefix);
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006305 } else {
6306 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006307 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006308 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006309 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006310 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006311 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006312 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006313 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006314 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6315 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6316 // operand.
6317 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6318 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006319}
6320
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006321void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6322 bool copyInit = false;
6323 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6324 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6325 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6326 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6327 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6328 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6329 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6330 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6331 }
6332 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6333 }
6334 else
6335 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6336 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6337 if (copyInit) {
6338 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006339 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006340 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6341 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6342 Owned(Arg));
6343 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006344 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006345 }
6346}
6347
6348
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006349/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006350/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006351/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6352/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6353/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6354/// - &(x) => x
6355/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6356/// - &s.xx => s
6357/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6358/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6359/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6360/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006361static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006362 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006363 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006364 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006365 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006366 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6367 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6368 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006369 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006370 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006371 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006372 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006373 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006374 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6375 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006376 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6377 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6378 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6379 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6380 }
6381 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006382 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006383 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6384 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006385
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006386 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006387 case UO_Real:
6388 case UO_Imag:
6389 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006390 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6391 default:
6392 return 0;
6393 }
6394 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006395 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006396 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006397 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006398 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6399 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006400 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006401 default:
6402 return 0;
6403 }
6404}
6405
6406/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006407/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006408/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006409/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006410/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006411/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006412/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006413QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6414 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006415 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006416 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6417 return Context.OverloadTy;
6418
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006419 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp, OpLoc);
6420 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6421 OrigOp = PR.take();
6422
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006423 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6424 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006425
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006426 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6427 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6428 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006429 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006430 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6431 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6432 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6433 }
6434 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6435 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6436 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006437 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006438 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006439
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006440 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006441 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6442 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6443 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6444 if (isSFINAEContext())
6445 return QualType();
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006446 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006447 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006448 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6449 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6450 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6451
6452 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6453 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6454 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6455 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6456 return QualType();
6457 }
6458 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6459 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6460
6461 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6462 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6463 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6464 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6465
6466 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6467 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6468 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6469 << op->getSourceRange();
6470 }
6471
6472 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6473 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6474 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006475 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006476 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006477 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006478 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006479 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6480 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006481 return QualType();
6482 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006483 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006484 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6485 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6486 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006487 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006488 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006489 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006490 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006491 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006492 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006493 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6494 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6495 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6496 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6497 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006498 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6499 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006500 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6501 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006502 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006503 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006504 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6505 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006506 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6507 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCall8e7d6562010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006508 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006509 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006510 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6511 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006512 return QualType();
6513 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006514 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006515 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006516 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006517 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006518 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6519 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006520 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006521 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006522 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6523 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006524 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006525 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6526 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6527 return QualType();
6528 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006529
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006530 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6531 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006532 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006533 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006534 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006535 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006536 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006537
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006538 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6539 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6540 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6541 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6542 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6543 }
6544
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006545 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006546 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6547 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006548 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006549}
6550
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006551/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006552QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006553 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6554 return Context.DependentTy;
6555
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006556 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006557 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6558 QualType Result;
6559
6560 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6561 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6562 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6563 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6564 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6565 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6566 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6567 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6568 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006569 else {
6570 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6571 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6572 if (PR.take() != Op) return CheckIndirectionOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc);
6573 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006574
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006575 if (Result.isNull()) {
6576 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6577 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6578 return QualType();
6579 }
6580
6581 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006582}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006583
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006584static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006585 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006586 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006587 switch (Kind) {
6588 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006589 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6590 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6591 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6592 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6593 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6594 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6595 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6596 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6597 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6598 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6599 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6600 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6601 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6602 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6603 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6604 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6605 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6606 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6607 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6608 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6609 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6610 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6611 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6612 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6613 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6614 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6615 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6616 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6617 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6618 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6619 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6620 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006621 }
6622 return Opc;
6623}
6624
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006625static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006626 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006627 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006628 switch (Kind) {
6629 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006630 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6631 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6632 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6633 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6634 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6635 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6636 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6637 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6638 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6639 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6640 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006641 }
6642 return Opc;
6643}
6644
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006645/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6646/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6647/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006648ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006649 unsigned Op,
6650 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006651 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006652 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006653 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6654 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6655 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006656
6657 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006658 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006659 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6660 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006661 case BO_PtrMemD:
6662 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006663 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006664 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006665 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006666 case BO_Mul:
6667 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006668 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006669 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006670 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006671 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006672 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6673 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006674 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006675 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6676 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006677 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006678 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6679 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006680 case BO_Shl:
6681 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006682 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6683 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006684 case BO_LE:
6685 case BO_LT:
6686 case BO_GE:
6687 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006688 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006689 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006690 case BO_EQ:
6691 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006692 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006693 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006694 case BO_And:
6695 case BO_Xor:
6696 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006697 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6698 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006699 case BO_LAnd:
6700 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006701 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006702 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006703 case BO_MulAssign:
6704 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006705 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006706 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006707 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6708 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6709 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006710 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006711 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006712 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6713 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6714 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6715 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006716 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006717 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006718 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6719 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6720 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006721 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006722 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006723 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6724 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6725 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006726 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006727 case BO_ShlAssign:
6728 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006729 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6730 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6731 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6732 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006733 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006734 case BO_AndAssign:
6735 case BO_XorAssign:
6736 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006737 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6738 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6739 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6740 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006741 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006742 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006743 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6744 break;
6745 }
6746 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006747 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006748 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006749 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006750 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6751 << ResultTy;
6752 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006753 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006754 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6755 else
6756 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006757 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6758 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006759}
6760
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006761/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6762/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006763static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6764 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006765 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6766 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6767 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006768 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006769 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6770
6771 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6772 return;
6773
6774 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6775 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6776 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006777 return;
6778 }
6779
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006780 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6781 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006782 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006783
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006784 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006785 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006786
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006787 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6788 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6789 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6790 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006791 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006792 return;
6793 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006794
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006795 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006796 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6797 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006798}
6799
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006800/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6801/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6802/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6803/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006804static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006805 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006806 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6807 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6808 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6809 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006810 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006811 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006812 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6813
6814 // Subs are not binary operators.
6815 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6816 return;
6817
6818 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6819 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006820 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6821 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006822 return;
6823
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006824 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006825 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006826 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006827 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6828 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006829 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006830 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006831 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6832 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6833 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6834 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006835 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006836 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006837 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006838 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6839 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006840 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006841 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006842 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6843 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6844 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6845 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006846}
6847
6848/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6849/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6850/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006851static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006852 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006853 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006854 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6855}
6856
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006857// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006858ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006859 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6860 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6861 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006862 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6863 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006864
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006865 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6866 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6867
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006868 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6869}
6870
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006871ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006872 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6873 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006874 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006875 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6876 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianaaf44b22010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006877 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006878 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006879 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6880 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6881 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6882 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6883 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006884 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006885 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006886 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6887 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6888 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006889
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006890 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6891 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006892 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006893 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006894
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006895 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006896 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006897}
6898
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006899ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006900 unsigned OpcIn,
6901 Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006902 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006903
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006904 QualType resultType;
6905 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006906 case UO_PreInc:
6907 case UO_PreDec:
6908 case UO_PostInc:
6909 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006910 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006911 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6912 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6913 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6914 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006915 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006916 case UO_AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006917 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006918 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006919 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006920 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006921 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006922 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006923 case UO_Plus:
6924 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006925 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6926 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006927 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6928 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006929 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6930 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006931 break;
6932 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6933 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6934 break;
6935 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006936 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006937 resultType->isPointerType())
6938 break;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006939 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6940 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6941 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6942 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6943 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006944
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006945 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6946 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006947 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006948 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6949 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006950 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6951 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006952 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6953 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6954 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006955 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006956 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006957 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6958 break;
6959 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6960 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6961 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6962 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6963 } else {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006964 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6965 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006966 }
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006967 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006968 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006969 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006970 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006971 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006972 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6973 break;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006974 if (resultType->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6975 // ok, fallthrough
6976 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6977 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6978 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6979 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6980 } else {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006981 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6982 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006983 }
Douglas Gregordb8c6fd2010-09-20 17:13:33 +00006984
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006985 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006986 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6987 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006988 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006989 case UO_Real:
6990 case UO_Imag:
6991 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006992 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006993 case UO_Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006994 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006995 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006996 }
6997 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006998 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006999
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007000 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00007001}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007002
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007003ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007004 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
7005 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00007006 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman8ed2bac2010-09-05 23:15:52 +00007007 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007008 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
7009 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
7010 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
7011 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007012 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007013 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007014 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
7015 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
7016 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007017
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007018 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007019 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007020
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007021 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007022}
7023
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007024// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007025ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007026 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
7027 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007028}
7029
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00007030/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007031ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007032 SourceLocation LabLoc,
7033 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007034 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007035 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007036
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00007037 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
7038 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00007039 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007040 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007041
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007042 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007043 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007044 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
7045 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007046}
7047
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007048ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007049Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007050 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007051 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
7052 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
7053
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00007054 bool isFileScope
7055 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00007056 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007057 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00007058
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007059 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
7060 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
7061 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007062
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007063 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
7064 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
7065 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007066
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007067 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
7068 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
7069 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
7070 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
7071 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007072
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007073 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007074 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007075 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007076
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007077 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
7078 // expressions are not lvalues.
7079
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007080 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007081}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007082
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007083ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007084 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7085 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7086 unsigned NumComponents,
7087 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007088 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007089 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00007090 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007091
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007092 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7093 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7094 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007095 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007096 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7097 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
7098
7099 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7100 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
7101 if (!Dependent
7102 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
7103 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
7104 << TypeRange))
7105 return ExprError();
7106
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007107 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7108 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007109 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7110 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007111 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007112 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7113 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007114
7115 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7116 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7117 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7118 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7119 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7120 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7121 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7122 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7123 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7124 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7125 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7126 if(!AT)
7127 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7128 << CurrentType);
7129 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7130 } else
7131 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7132
7133 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7134 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7135 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7136 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7137 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7138 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7139 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7140 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7141
7142 // Record this array index.
7143 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7144 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7145 continue;
7146 }
7147
7148 // Offset of a field.
7149 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7150 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7151 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7152 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7153 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7154 continue;
7155 }
7156
7157 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7158 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7159 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7160 return ExprError();
7161
7162 // Look for the designated field.
7163 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7164 if (!RC)
7165 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7166 << CurrentType);
7167 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7168
7169 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7170 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7171 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7172 // (clause 9).
7173 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7174 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7175 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7176 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7177 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7178 << CurrentType))
7179 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7180 }
7181
7182 // Look for the field.
7183 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7184 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7185 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7186 if (!MemberDecl)
7187 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7188 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7189 OC.LocEnd));
7190
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007191 // C99 7.17p3:
7192 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7193 //
7194 // We diagnose this as an error.
7195 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7196 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7197 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7198 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7199 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7200 return ExprError();
7201 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007202
7203 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7204 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7205 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7206 do {
7207 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7208 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7209 }
7210
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007211 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7212 // the base class indirections.
7213 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7214 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007215 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007216 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7217 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7218 B != BEnd; ++B)
7219 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7220 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007221
7222 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007223 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7224 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7225 unsigned n = Path.size();
7226 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7227 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7228 } else {
7229 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7230 }
7231 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7232 }
7233
7234 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7235 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7236 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7237}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007238
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007239ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007240 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7241 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7242 ParsedType argty,
7243 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7244 unsigned NumComponents,
7245 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7246
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007247 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7248 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7249 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7250 return ExprError();
7251
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007252 if (!ArgTInfo)
7253 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7254
7255 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7256 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007257}
7258
7259
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007260ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007261 ParsedType arg1, ParsedType arg2,
7262 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007263 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7264 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7265 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7266 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007267
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007268 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007269
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007270 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7271}
7272
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007273ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007274Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7275 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7276 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7277 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007278 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7279 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7280 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7281 return ExprError();
7282 }
7283
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007284 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007285 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007286}
7287
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007288
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007289ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007290 Expr *CondExpr,
7291 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7292 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007293 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7294
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007295 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007296 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007297 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007298 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007299 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007300 } else {
7301 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7302 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7303 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7304 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007305 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7306 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7307 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007308
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007309 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7310 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007311 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7312 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007313 }
7314
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007315 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007316 resType, RPLoc,
7317 resType->isDependentType(),
7318 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007319}
7320
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007321//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7322// Clang Extensions.
7323//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7324
7325/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007326void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007327 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7328 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7329 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007330 if (BlockScope)
7331 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7332 else
7333 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007334}
7335
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007336void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007337 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007338 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007339
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007340 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007341 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007342 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007343
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007344 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007345 QualType RetTy;
7346 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007347 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007348 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007349 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007350 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7351 } else {
7352 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007353 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007354 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007355
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007356 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007357
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007358 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7359 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7360 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007361 return;
7362 }
7363
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007364 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7365 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7366 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7367 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7368 return;
7369 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007370
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007371 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007372 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7373 // ^ * { ... }
7374 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007375 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7376 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007377
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007378 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007379 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007380 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7381 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7382 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7383 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007384 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7385 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7386 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7387 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7388 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007389 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007390 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007391
7392 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7393 // ^ fntype { ... }
7394 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7395 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7396 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7397 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7398 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7399 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7400 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007401 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007402 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007403 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007404
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007405 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7406 if (!Params.empty())
7407 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007408
7409 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007410 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007411
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007412 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007413 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7414 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7415 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7416 }
7417
7418 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7419 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007420 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007421 return;
7422
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007423 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7424 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7425
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007426 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007427 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7428 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7429
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007430 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007431 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7432 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7433 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7434
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007435 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007436 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007437 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007438}
7439
7440/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7441/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7442void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007443 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007444 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007445 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007446 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007447}
7448
7449/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7450/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007451ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007452 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007453 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7454 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7455 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007456
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007457 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007458
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007459 PopDeclContext();
7460
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007461 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007462 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7463 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007464
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007465 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007466 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007467
7468 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7469 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7470 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7471
7472 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7473 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7474
7475 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7476 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7477 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7478 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7479
7480 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7481 // preserve its sugar structure.
7482 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7483 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7484 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7485
7486 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7487 } else {
7488 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7489 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7490 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7491 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7492 FPT->isVariadic(),
7493 /*quals*/ 0,
7494 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7495 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7496 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7497 FPT->exception_begin(),
7498 Ext);
7499 }
7500
7501 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7502 } else {
7503 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7504 false, false, 0, 0,
7505 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7506 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007507
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007508 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007509 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7510 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007511 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007512
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007513 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007514 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007515 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007516
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007517 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007518
7519 bool Good = true;
7520 // Check goto/label use.
7521 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7522 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7523 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7524
7525 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7526 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007527 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7528 if (!L->isUsed())
7529 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007530 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007531 }
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007532
7533 // Emit error.
7534 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7535 Good = false;
7536 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007537 if (!Good) {
7538 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007539 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007540 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007541
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007542 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7543 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7544
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007545 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007546 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7547 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007548 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007549
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007550 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007551 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007552}
7553
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007554ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007555 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007556 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007557 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7558 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007559 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007560}
7561
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007562ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007563 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007564 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007565 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007566
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007567 // Get the va_list type
7568 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007569 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7570 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7571 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7572 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007573 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007574 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7575 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7576 } else {
7577 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7578 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007579 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007580 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007581 return ExprError();
7582 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007583
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007584 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7585 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007586 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7587 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007588 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007589 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007590
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007591 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007592 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007593
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007594 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7595 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007596}
7597
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007598ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007599 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7600 // pointers on the target.
7601 QualType Ty;
7602 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7603 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7604 else
7605 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7606
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007607 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007608}
7609
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007610static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007611 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007612 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7613 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007614
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007615 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7616 if (!PT)
7617 return;
7618
7619 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7620 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7621 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7622 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7623 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7624 return;
7625 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007626
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007627 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7628 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7629 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7630 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007631
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007632 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007633}
7634
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007635bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7636 SourceLocation Loc,
7637 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007638 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7639 bool *Complained) {
7640 if (Complained)
7641 *Complained = false;
7642
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007643 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7644 bool isInvalid = false;
7645 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007646 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007647
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007648 switch (ConvTy) {
7649 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7650 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007651 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007652 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7653 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007654 case IntToPointer:
7655 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7656 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007657 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007658 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007659 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7660 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007661 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7662 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7663 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007664 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7665 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7666 break;
7667 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007668 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7669 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7670 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7671 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7672 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7673 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7674 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7675 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7676 // C++ semantics.
7677 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7678 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7679 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007680 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7681 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007682 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007683 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007684 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007685 case IntToBlockPointer:
7686 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7687 break;
7688 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007689 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007690 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007691 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007692 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007693 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7694 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7695 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007696 case IncompatibleVectors:
7697 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7698 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007699 case Incompatible:
7700 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7701 isInvalid = true;
7702 break;
7703 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007704
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007705 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7706 switch (Action) {
7707 case AA_Assigning:
7708 case AA_Initializing:
7709 // The destination type comes first.
7710 FirstType = DstType;
7711 SecondType = SrcType;
7712 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007713
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007714 case AA_Returning:
7715 case AA_Passing:
7716 case AA_Converting:
7717 case AA_Sending:
7718 case AA_Casting:
7719 // The source type comes first.
7720 FirstType = SrcType;
7721 SecondType = DstType;
7722 break;
7723 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007724
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007725 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007726 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007727 if (Complained)
7728 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007729 return isInvalid;
7730}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007731
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007732bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007733 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7734 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7735 if (Result)
7736 *Result = ICEResult;
7737 return false;
7738 }
7739
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007740 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7741
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007742 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007743 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7744 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7745
7746 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7747 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7748 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7749 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7750 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7751 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7752 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007753
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007754 return true;
7755 }
7756
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007757 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7758 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007759
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007760 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7761 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7762 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007763
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007764 if (Result)
7765 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7766 return false;
7767}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007768
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007769void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007770Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007771 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7772 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007773}
7774
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007775void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007776Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7777 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7778 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7779 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007780
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007781 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7782 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7783 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7784 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7785 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007786 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007787 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7788 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7789 I != IEnd; ++I)
7790 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7791 }
7792
7793 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7794 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7795 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7796 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7797 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7798 I != IEnd; ++I)
7799 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7800 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007801 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007802
7803 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7804 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7805 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7806 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007807 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007808 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7809 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7810 ExprTemporaries.end());
7811
7812 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7813 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007814}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007815
7816/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7817///
7818/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7819/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7820/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7821/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7822///
7823/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7824///
7825/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7826void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7827 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007828
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007829 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007830 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007831
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007832 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7833 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7834 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7835 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007836 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007837 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Anders Carlsson73067a02010-10-22 23:37:08 +00007838 D->setUsed();
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007839 return;
7840 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007841
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007842 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7843 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007844
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007845 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7846 // an instantiation.
7847 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7848 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007849
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007850 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007851 case Unevaluated:
7852 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7853 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007854
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007855 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7856 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7857 // "used"; handle this below.
7858 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007859
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007860 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7861 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7862 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7863 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007864 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007865 return;
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007866
7867 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7868 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7869 // containing expression is used.
7870 return;
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007871 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007872
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007873 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007874 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007875 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007876 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruthc9262402010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007877 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7878 return;
7879 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7880 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007881 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007882 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007883 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007884 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7885 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007886
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007887 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007888 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007889 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007890 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007891 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7892 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007893 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7894 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7895 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007896 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007897 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007898 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7899 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007900 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007901 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007902 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007903 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007904 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007905 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7906 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7907 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7908 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7909 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007910 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007911 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007912 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007913 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007914 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7915 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7916 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007917 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007918 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007919 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7920 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007921
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007922 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7923 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7924 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7925 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7926 Loc));
7927 else
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007928 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007929 }
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007930 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7931 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7932 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greif34ecff22010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007933 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007934 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7935 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007936
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007937 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidisdfffabd2010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007938
7939 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7940 if (CurContext != Function)
7941 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007942
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007943 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007944 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007945
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007946 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007947 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007948 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007949 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7950 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7951 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7952 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7953 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7954 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007955 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007956 }
7957 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007958
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007959 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007960
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007961 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007962 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007963 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007964}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007965
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007966namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007967 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007968 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007969 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007970 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7971 Sema &S;
7972 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007973
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007974 public:
7975 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007976
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007977 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007978
7979 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7980 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007981 };
7982}
7983
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007984bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7985 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007986 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7987 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7988 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007989
7990 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007991}
7992
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007993bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007994 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7995 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7996 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007997 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7998 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007999 }
8000
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00008001 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008002}
8003
8004void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
8005 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008006 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008007}
8008
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008009namespace {
8010 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
8011 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8012 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
8013 Sema &S;
8014
8015 public:
8016 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
8017
8018 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
8019
8020 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
8021 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8022 }
8023
8024 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
8025 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008026 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008027 }
8028
8029 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
8030 if (E->getConstructor())
8031 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
8032 if (E->getOperatorNew())
8033 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
8034 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8035 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008036 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008037 }
8038
8039 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
8040 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8041 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00008042 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
8043 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8044 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
8045 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
8046 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
8047 }
8048
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008049 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008050 }
8051
8052 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
8053 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008054 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008055 }
8056
8057 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
8058 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8059 }
Douglas Gregorf0873f42010-10-19 17:17:35 +00008060
8061 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
8062 Visit(E->getExpr());
8063 }
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008064 };
8065}
8066
8067/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
8068/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8069void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
8070 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
8071}
8072
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008073/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
8074/// of the program being compiled.
8075///
8076/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008077/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008078/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
8079/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
8080/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
8081/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008082/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008083/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008084///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008085/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
8086/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
8087/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
8088/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008089bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008090 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
8091 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
8092 case Unevaluated:
8093 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
8094 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008095
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008096 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008097 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008098 Diag(Loc, PD);
8099 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008100
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008101 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8102 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
8103 break;
8104 }
8105
8106 return false;
8107}
8108
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008109bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8110 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8111 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8112 return false;
8113
8114 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8115 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8116 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8117 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008118
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008119 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008120 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008121 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8122 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008123 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008124 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8125 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8126 return true;
8127
8128 return false;
8129}
8130
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008131// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8132// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8133void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8134 SourceLocation Loc;
8135
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008136 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8137
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008138 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8139 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008140 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008141 return;
8142
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008143 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8144 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8145 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8146 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8147
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008148 // self = [<foo> init...]
8149 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8150 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8151 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8152
8153 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8154 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8155 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8156 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8157 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008158
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008159 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8160 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8161 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8162 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8163 return;
8164
8165 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8166 } else {
8167 // Not an assignment.
8168 return;
8169 }
8170
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008171 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008172 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008173
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008174 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008175 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008176 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008177 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8178 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8179 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008180}
8181
8182bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8183 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8184
8185 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008186 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008187
8188 QualType T = E->getType();
8189
8190 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8191 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8192 return true;
8193 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8194 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8195 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8196 return true;
8197 }
8198 }
8199
8200 return false;
8201}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008202
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008203ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8204 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008205 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008206 return ExprError();
8207
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008208 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008209 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008210
8211 return Owned(Sub);
8212}
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008213
8214/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
8215/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
8216ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8217 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8218 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
8219
8220 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
8221 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
8222 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
8223 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
8224 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
8225 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
8226 Specialization->getAccess());
8227 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
8228 if (!E) return ExprError();
8229 return Owned(E);
8230 }
8231
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008232 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ovl_unresolvable) << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008233 return ExprError();
8234 }
8235
8236 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
8237 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
8238
8239 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
8240 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
8241 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
8242 return ExprError();
8243}